blob: 6a62a1a12dfdc466b3e2142384692c5ce64bf0d5 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Sema.h"
15#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000462Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000463Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000464 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000465 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
466 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
467}
468
469/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
470Sema::OwningExprResult
471Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
472 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
473 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000474 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000476 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 << D->getDeclName();
478 return ExprError();
479 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000480
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000481 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000482 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
483 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
484 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000485 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000486 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000487 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
488 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000489 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
490 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000493 << D->getIdentifier();
494 return ExprError();
495 }
496 }
497 }
498 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000501
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000502 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
503 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
504 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000505 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000506}
507
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000508/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
509/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
510/// actual member.
511///
512/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
513/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
514/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
515/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
516/// we found.
517///
518/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
519/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
520/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
521VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
522 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000523 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
524 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
525 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
526
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000527 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000528 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
529 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
530 do {
531 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000532 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000535 else {
536 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
537 break;
538 }
539 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000540 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000541 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000542
543 return BaseObject;
544}
545
546Sema::OwningExprResult
547Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
548 FieldDecl *Field,
549 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
550 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
551 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000552 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000553 AnonFields);
554
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000555 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
556 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
557 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
558 // found via name lookup.
559 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000560 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 if (BaseObject) {
562 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
563 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000565 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000566 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 BaseQuals
568 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000569 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
570 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
571 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
572 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
573 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000574 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
576 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
577 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000578 BaseQuals
579 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 } else {
581 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
582 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
583 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000584 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
585 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000587 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000588 = Context.getTagDeclType(
589 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
590 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000591 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
593 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
594 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000595 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000596 MD->getThisType(Context),
597 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
599 }
600 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000601 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
602 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000603 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000604 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 }
606
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000607 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000608 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
609 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000610 }
611
612 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
613 // anonymous struct/union.
614 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000615 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000616 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
617 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
618 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
619 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000620 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
621 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
622
623 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
624 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
625 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
626 ResultQuals.removeConst();
627
628 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
629 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
630
631 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
632 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
633
634 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
635 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
636 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
637
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000638 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000639 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000640 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000641 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
642 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000643 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000644 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000645 }
646
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000647 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648}
649
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000650/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000651/// possibly a list of template arguments.
652///
653/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
654/// DecomposeTemplateName.
655///
656/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
657/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
658/// some way.
659static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
660 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
661 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000662 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
664 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
665 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
666 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
667
668 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
669 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
670 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
671 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
672 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
673
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000674 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000675 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
676 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000677 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
678 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000679 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680 TemplateArgs = 0;
681 }
682}
683
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
685/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
686/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000688 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
689 return false;
690
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000691 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
692 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
693 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
694 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
695 if (!BaseRT) return false;
696
697 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000698 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000699 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
700 return false;
701 }
702
703 return true;
704}
705
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000706/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
707/// the prospective base classes.
708static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
709 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
710 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000711 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000712 return false;
713
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000714 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000715 if (!RD) return false;
716 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
717
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000718 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
719 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
720 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
721 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
722 if (!BaseRT) return false;
723
724 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
726 return false;
727 }
728
729 return true;
730}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000731
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000732enum IMAKind {
733 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
734 IMA_Static,
735
736 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
737 IMA_Mixed,
738
739 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
740 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
741 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
742
743 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
744 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
745 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
746
747 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
748 IMA_Instance,
749
750 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
751 IMA_Unresolved,
752
753 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
754 /// context is not an instance method.
755 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
756
757 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
758 /// non-class context.
759 IMA_AnonymousMember,
760
761 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
762 /// context is not an instance method.
763 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
764
765 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
766 /// class.
767 IMA_Error_Unrelated
768};
769
770/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
771/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
772/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
773/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
774/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
775/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
776static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
777 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000778 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000779
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000780 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000781 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000782 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
783 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000784
785 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
786 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
787
788 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
789 bool hasNonInstance = false;
790 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
791 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000792 NamedDecl *D = *I;
793 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
795
796 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
797 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
798 // that's a special case.
799 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
800 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
801 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
802 }
803 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
804 }
805 else
806 hasNonInstance = true;
807 }
808
809 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
810 // member reference.
811 if (Classes.empty())
812 return IMA_Static;
813
814 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
815 // an implicit member reference.
816 if (isStaticContext)
817 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
818
819 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
820 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
821 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
822 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000823 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000824 Classes))
825 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
826
827 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
828}
829
830/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
831static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
832 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
833 const LookupResult &R) {
834 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
835 SourceRange Range(Loc);
836 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
837
838 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
839 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
840 if (MD->isStatic()) {
841 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
842 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
843 << Range << R.getLookupName();
844 return;
845 }
846 }
847
848 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
849 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
850 return;
851 }
852
853 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000854}
855
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000856/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
857///
858/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000859bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
860 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000861 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
862
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000863 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000864 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000865 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
866 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000867 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000869 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
870 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000872 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
873 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
874 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
875 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000876 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
879 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
880
881 if (!R.empty()) {
882 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
883 R.suppressDiagnostics();
884
885 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
886 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
887 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
888 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
889
890 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
891 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
892 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000893 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000894 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
895 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000896 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000898 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000899 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
900 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
901 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
902 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
903 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
904 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
905 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
906 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
907 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
908 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
909 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
910 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
911 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
912 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000913 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000914 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
915 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
916 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000917 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000918 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000919 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000920 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000921
922 // Do we really want to note all of these?
923 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
924 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
925
926 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
927 return false;
928 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000929
930 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000931 }
932 }
933
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000934 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000935 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000936 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000937 if (!R.empty()) {
938 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
939 if (SS.isEmpty())
940 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
941 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
942 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
943 else
944 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
945 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
946 << SS.getRange()
947 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
948 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
949 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
950 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
951 << ND->getDeclName();
952
953 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
954 return false;
955 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000956
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000957 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
958 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
959 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
960 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
961 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
962 // to recover well anyway.
963 if (SS.isEmpty())
964 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
965 else
966 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
967 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
968 << SS.getRange();
969
970 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
971 return true;
972 }
973 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000974 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000975 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000976 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000977 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000978 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000979 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000980 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
981 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 return true;
983 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000984 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000985 }
986
987 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
988 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
989 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
990 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
991 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
992 << SS.getRange();
993 return true;
994 }
995
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000996 // Give up, we can't recover.
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
998 return true;
999}
1000
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001001static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001002 IdentifierInfo *II,
1003 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001004 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1005 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1006 if (!IDecl)
1007 return 0;
1008 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1009 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1010 return 0;
1011 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1012 if (!property)
1013 return 0;
1014 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1015 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1016 return 0;
1017 return property;
1018}
1019
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001020static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001021 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001022 IdentifierInfo *II,
1023 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1024 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001025 bool LookForIvars;
1026 if (Lookup.empty())
1027 LookForIvars = true;
1028 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1029 LookForIvars = false;
1030 else
1031 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1032 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1033 if (!LookForIvars)
1034 return 0;
1035
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001036 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1037 if (!IDecl)
1038 return 0;
1039 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001040 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1041 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001042 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1043 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1044 if (!property)
1045 return 0;
1046 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1047 DynamicImplSeen =
1048 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1049 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001050 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1051 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001052 NameLoc,
1053 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1054 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1055 (Expr *)0, true);
1056 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1057 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1058 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1059 return Ivar;
1060 }
1061 return 0;
1062}
1063
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001064Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001065 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1067 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1068 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1069 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1070 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1071
1072 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001073 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001074
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001075 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076
1077 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001078 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001080 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001081
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001082 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001083 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001084 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001085
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1087 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001088 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1089 // (note: handled after lookup)
1090 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1091 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1092 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1094 // names a dependent type.
1095 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1096 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001097 bool DependentID = false;
1098 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1099 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1100 DependentID = true;
1101 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1102 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1103 if (DC) {
1104 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1105 return ExprError();
1106 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1107 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1108 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1109 } else {
1110 DependentID = true;
1111 }
1112 }
1113
1114 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001115 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 TemplateArgs);
1117 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001118 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001120 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001121 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001122 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1123 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1124 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1125 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1126 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001127 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1128 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1129 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001131 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001132 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001133
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001134 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1135 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001136 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1137 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001138 if (E.isInvalid())
1139 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001140
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1142 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001143 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1144 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001145 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001146 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1147 isAddressOfOperand);
1148 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001149 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1150 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001151 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001152 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001153
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001154 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1155 return ExprError();
1156
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001157 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1158 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001159 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001160
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001161 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001162 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1164 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1165 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1166 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1167 }
1168
1169 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1170 // call, diagnose the problem.
1171 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001172 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001173 return ExprError();
1174
1175 assert(!R.empty() &&
1176 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001177
1178 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1179 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001180 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001181 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1182 R.clear();
1183 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1184 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1185 return move(E);
1186 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001187 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001188 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001189
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001190 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1191 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1192
1193 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001194 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001195 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1196 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001197 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1198 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1199 if (Property) {
1200 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1201 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001202 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001203 }
1204 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001205 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001206 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1207 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1208 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1209 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1210 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1211 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001212 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001213 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001214
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001215 QualType T = Func->getType();
1216 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001217 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001218 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1219 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001221 }
1222 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001223
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001224 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1225 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1226 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1227 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1228 // class member access expression.
1229 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1230 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001231 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001232 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001233 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1234 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001235 }
1236
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001237 if (TemplateArgs)
1238 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001239
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001240 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1241}
1242
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001243/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1244Sema::OwningExprResult
1245Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1246 LookupResult &R,
1247 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1248 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1249 case IMA_Instance:
1250 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1251
1252 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1253 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1254 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1255 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1256
1257 case IMA_Mixed:
1258 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1259 case IMA_Unresolved:
1260 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1261
1262 case IMA_Static:
1263 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1264 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1265 if (TemplateArgs)
1266 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1267 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1268
1269 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1270 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1271 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1272 return ExprError();
1273 }
1274
1275 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1276 return ExprError();
1277}
1278
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001279/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1280/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1281/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1282/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001283Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001284Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001285 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001286 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001287 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001288 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001289
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001290 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001291 return ExprError();
1292
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001293 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001294 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1295
1296 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1297 return ExprError();
1298
1299 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001300 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1301 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001302 return ExprError();
1303 }
1304
1305 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1306}
1307
1308/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1309/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1310/// additional lookup.
1311///
1312/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1313/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1314///
1315/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1316Sema::OwningExprResult
1317Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001318 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001319 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001320 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001321
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001322 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1323 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1324 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1325 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1326 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1327
1328 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1329 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1330 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001331 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332
1333 bool LookForIvars;
1334 if (Lookup.empty())
1335 LookForIvars = true;
1336 else if (IsClassMethod)
1337 LookForIvars = false;
1338 else
1339 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1340 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001341 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001342 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001343 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001344 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1345 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1346 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1347 if (IsClassMethod)
1348 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1349 << IV->getDeclName());
1350
1351 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1352 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1353 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1354 return ExprError();
1355
1356 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1357 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1358 return ExprError();
1359
1360 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1361 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1362 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1363 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1364
1365 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1366 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1367 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1368 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001369 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1371 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1372 SelfName, false, false);
1373 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1374 return Owned(new (Context)
1375 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1376 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1377 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001378 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001380 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001381 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1382 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1383 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1384 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1385 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1386 }
1387 }
1388
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001389 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1390 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1391 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1392 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1393 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1394 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1395 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1396 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1397 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1398 }
1399 }
1400 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001401 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1402 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001403}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001404
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001405/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1406///
1407/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1408///
1409/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1410/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1411/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1412/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1413///
1414/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1415/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1416/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1417/// the class declaring the member.
1418///
1419/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1420/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1421/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001422bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001423Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1424 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001425 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001426 NamedDecl *Member) {
1427 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1428 if (!RD)
1429 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001430
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001431 QualType DestRecordType;
1432 QualType DestType;
1433 QualType FromRecordType;
1434 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1435 bool PointerConversions = false;
1436 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1437 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001438
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001439 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1440 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1441 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1442 PointerConversions = true;
1443 } else {
1444 DestType = DestRecordType;
1445 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001446 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001447 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1448 if (Method->isStatic())
1449 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001450
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001451 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1452 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001453
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001454 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1455 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1456 PointerConversions = true;
1457 } else {
1458 FromRecordType = FromType;
1459 DestType = DestRecordType;
1460 }
1461 } else {
1462 // No conversion necessary.
1463 return false;
1464 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001465
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001466 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001469 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1470 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1471 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001472
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001473 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1474 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1475
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001476 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1477
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001480 // class name.
1481 //
1482 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1483 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1484 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1485 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1486 //
1487 // class Base { public: int x; };
1488 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1489 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1490 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1491 //
1492 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1493 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1494 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1495 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001496 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1498 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1499 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1500
1501 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1502
1503 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1504 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1505 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1506 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001507 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001508 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001509 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001510 return true;
1511
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001512 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001513 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001514 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001515 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001516
1517 FromType = QType;
1518 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1519
1520 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1521 // we're done.
1522 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1523 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001524 }
1525 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001526
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001527 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001528
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001529 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1530 // down to the using declaration's type.
1531 //
1532 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1533 // class ever has member declarations.
1534 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1535 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1536 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1537 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1538
1539 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1540 // conversion is non-trivial.
1541 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1542 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001543 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001544 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001545 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001546 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001547
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 QualType UType = URecordType;
1549 if (PointerConversions)
1550 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001551 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001552 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001553 FromType = UType;
1554 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1555 }
1556
1557 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1558 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1559 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001560 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001561
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001562 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001563 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1564 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001565 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001566 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001567
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001568 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001569 Category, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001570 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001571}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001572
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001573/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001574static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001575 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001576 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001577 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1578 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001579 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1580 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1581 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001582 if (SS.isSet()) {
1583 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1584 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001585 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001586
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001587 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001588 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1589 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001590}
1591
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001592/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1593/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1594/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1595/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001596Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001597Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1598 LookupResult &R,
1599 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1600 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001601 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1602
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001603 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001604
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001605 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1606 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001607 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001608 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001609 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001610 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001611 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001612
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001613 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1614 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001615 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1616 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001617 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1618 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001619 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1620 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1621 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1622 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001623 }
1624
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001625 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1626 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1627 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001628 SS,
1629 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1630 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001631}
1632
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001633bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001634 const LookupResult &R,
1635 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001636 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1637 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1638 return false;
1639
1640 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001641 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001642 return false;
1643
1644 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001645 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001646 return false;
1647
1648 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1649 // normal lookup:
1650 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1651 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1652
1653 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1654 // -- a declaration of a class member
1655 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1656 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001657 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001658 return false;
1659
1660 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1661 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1662 // using-declaration
1663 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1664 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1665 // turn off ADL anyway).
1666 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1667 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1668 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1669 return false;
1670
1671 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1672 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1673 // template
1674 // And also for builtin functions.
1675 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1676 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1677
1678 // But also builtin functions.
1679 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1680 return false;
1681 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1682 return false;
1683 }
1684
1685 return true;
1686}
1687
1688
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001689/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1690/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1691/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1692/// will in fact be used.
1693static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1694 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1695 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1696 return true;
1697 }
1698
1699 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1700 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1701 return true;
1702 }
1703
1704 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1705 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1706 return true;
1707 }
1708
1709 return false;
1710}
1711
1712Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001713Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001714 LookupResult &R,
1715 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001716 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1717 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001718 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001719 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1720 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001721
1722 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1723 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1724 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001725 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1726 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727 return ExprError();
1728
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001729 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1730 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1731 // we've picked a target.
1732 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1733
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001734 bool Dependent
1735 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001736 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001737 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001738 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001739 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001740 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1741 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001742
1743 return Owned(ULE);
1744}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001745
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001746
1747/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1748Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001749Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001750 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1751 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001752 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001753 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1754 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001755
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001756 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001757 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1758 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001759
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001760 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1761 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1762 // a template argument list.
1763 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1764 << Template << SS.getRange();
1765 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1766 return ExprError();
1767 }
1768
1769 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1770 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1771 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001772 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001773 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001774 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001775 return ExprError();
1776 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001778 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1779 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1780 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1781 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001782 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001783 return ExprError();
1784
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001785 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1786 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001787 return ExprError();
1788
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001789 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1790 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1791 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1792 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001793 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001794 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1795 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1796 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001797 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001798 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001799 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1800 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1801 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1802 return ExprError();
1803 }
1804
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001805 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001806 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1807 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1808 return ExprError();
1809 }
1810
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001811 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001812 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001813 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001814 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001815 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001816 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1817 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001818 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001819
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001820 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001821 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001822 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1823 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001824 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001825 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1826 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1827 Expr *E = new (Context)
1828 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1829 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001830
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001831 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1832 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001833 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001834 SourceLocation(),
1835 Owned(E));
1836 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1837 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1838 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1839 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1840 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001841 }
1842 }
1843 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001844 }
1845 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1846 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001847
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001848 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1849 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001850}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001851
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001852Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1853 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001854 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001855
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001856 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001857 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001858 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1859 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1860 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001861 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001862
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001863 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1864 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001865
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001866 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001867 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1868 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001869 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001870 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001871 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001872 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001873
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001874 QualType ResTy;
1875 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1876 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1877 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001878 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001879
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001880 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001881 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001882 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1883 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001884 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001885}
1886
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001887Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001888 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001889 bool Invalid = false;
1890 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1891 if (Invalid)
1892 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001893
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001894 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1895 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001896 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001897 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001898
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001899 QualType Ty;
1900 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1901 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1902 else if (Literal.isWide())
1903 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001904 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1905 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001906 else
1907 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001908
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001909 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1910 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001911 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001912}
1913
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1915 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001916 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1917 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001918 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001919 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001920 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001921 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001922 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001923
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001924 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001925 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1926 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001927 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001928
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001929 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001930 bool Invalid = false;
1931 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1932 if (Invalid)
1933 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001935 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001936 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001937 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001938 return ExprError();
1939
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001940 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001942 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001943 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001944 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001945 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001946 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001947 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001948 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001949 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001950
1951 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1952
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001953 using llvm::APFloat;
1954 APFloat Val(Format);
1955
1956 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001957
1958 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1959 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1960 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1961 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001962 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001963 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001964 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001965 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001966 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1967 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001968 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001969 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1970 }
1971
1972 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1973 << Ty
1974 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1975 }
1976
1977 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001978 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001980 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001981 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001982 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001984
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001985 // long long is a C99 feature.
1986 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001987 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001988 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1989
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001990 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001991 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001992
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001993 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1994 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1995 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001996 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1997 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001998 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001999 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002000 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2001 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002002
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002003 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2004 // be an unsigned int.
2005 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2006
2007 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002008 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002009 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2010 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002011 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002012
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002013 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2014 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2015 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2016 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002017 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002018 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002019 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002020 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002021 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002022 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002023
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002024 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002025 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002026 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002027
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002028 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2029 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2030 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2031 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002032 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002033 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002034 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002035 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002036 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002037 }
2038
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002039 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002040 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002041 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002042
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002043 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2044 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2045 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2046 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002047 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002048 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002049 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002050 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 }
2052 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002053
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002054 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2055 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002056 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002057 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002058 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002059 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002060 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002061
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002062 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2063 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002064 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002065 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002066 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002067
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002068 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2069 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002070 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002071 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002072
2073 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002074}
2075
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002076Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2077 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002078 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002079 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002080 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002081}
2082
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002083/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002084/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002085bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002086 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2087 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2088 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002089 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2090 return false;
2091
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002092 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2093 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2094 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2095 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2096 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2097 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2098
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002099 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002100 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002101 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002102 if (isSizeof)
2103 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2104 return false;
2105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002106
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002107 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002108 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2110 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002111 return false;
2112 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002113
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002114 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002115 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2116 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002117 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002118
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002119 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002120 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002121 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002122 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2123 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002124 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002125
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002126 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2127 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2128 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2129 return true;
2130 }
2131
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002132 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002133}
2134
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002135bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2136 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2137 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002138
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002139 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002140 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2141 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002142
2143 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2144 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2145 return false;
2146
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002147 if (E->getBitField()) {
2148 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2149 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002150 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002151
2152 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2153 // bit-field.
2154 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002155 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002156 return false;
2157
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002158 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2159}
2160
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002161/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002163Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002164 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002165 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002166 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002167 return ExprError();
2168
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002169 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002170
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002171 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2172 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2173 return ExprError();
2174
2175 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002176 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002177 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2178 R.getEnd()));
2179}
2180
2181/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2182/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002183Action::OwningExprResult
2184Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002185 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2186 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2187 bool isInvalid = false;
2188 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2189 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2190 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2191 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002192 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002193 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2194 isInvalid = true;
2195 } else {
2196 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2197 }
2198
2199 if (isInvalid)
2200 return ExprError();
2201
2202 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2203 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2204 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2205 R.getEnd()));
2206}
2207
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002208/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2209/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2210/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002211Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002212Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2213 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002214 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002215 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002216
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002217 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002218 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2219 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2220 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002221 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002222
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002223 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2224 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2225 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2226
2227 if (Result.isInvalid())
2228 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2229
2230 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002231}
2232
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002233QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002234 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2235 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002237 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002238 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002239 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002240
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002241 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2242 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2243 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002244
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002245 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002246 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2247 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002248 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002249}
2250
2251
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002252
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002253Action::OwningExprResult
2254Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2255 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002256 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2257 switch (Kind) {
2258 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2259 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2260 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2261 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002262
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002263 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002264}
2265
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002266Action::OwningExprResult
2267Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2268 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002269 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2270 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2271
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002272 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2273 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002274
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002275 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002276 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2277 Base.release();
2278 Idx.release();
2279 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2280 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2281 }
2282
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002283 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002284 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002285 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2286 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2287 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002288 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002289 }
2290
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002291 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2292}
2293
2294
2295Action::OwningExprResult
2296Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2297 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2298 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2299 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2300
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002301 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002302 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2304 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002305
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002306 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002307
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002308 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002309 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002310 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002311 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002312 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2313 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002314 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2315 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2316 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2317 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002318 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002319 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2320 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002321 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002322 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002323 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002324 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2325 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002326 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002327 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002328 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002329 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2330 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2331 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002332 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002333 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002334 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2335 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2336 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2337 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002338 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002339 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002340 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002341
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002342 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2343 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002344 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2345 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002346 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002347 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2348 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2349 // force the promotion here.
2350 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2351 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002352 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2353 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002354 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2355
2356 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2357 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002358 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002359 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2360 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2361 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2362 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002363 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2364 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002365 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2366
2367 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2368 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002369 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002370 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002371 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2372 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002373 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002374 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002375 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002376 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2377 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002378
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002379 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002380 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2381 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002382 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2383
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002384 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002385 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2386 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002387 // incomplete types are not object types.
2388 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2389 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2390 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2391 return ExprError();
2392 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002393
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002394 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002395 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002396 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2397 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002398 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002399
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002400 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002401 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002402 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2403 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2404 return ExprError();
2405 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002406
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002407 Base.release();
2408 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002409 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002410 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002411}
2412
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002413QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002414CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002415 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002416 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002417 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2418 // see FIXME there.
2419 //
2420 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2421 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002422 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002423
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002424 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002425 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002426
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002427 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002428 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2429 // to be selected.
2430 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002431
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002432 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2433 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002434 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002435
2436 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2437 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002438 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002439 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2440 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002441 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002442 do
2443 compStr++;
2444 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002445 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002446 do
2447 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002448 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002449 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002450
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002451 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002452 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2453 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002455 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002456 return QualType();
2457 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002458
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002459 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2460 // operates on.
2461 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002462 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002463
2464 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002465 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002466
2467 while (*compStr) {
2468 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2469 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2470 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2471 return QualType();
2472 }
2473 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002474 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002475
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002476 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002477 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002478 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002479 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002480 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002481 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002482 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002483 if (HexSwizzle)
2484 CompSize--;
2485
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002486 if (CompSize == 1)
2487 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002488
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002489 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002490 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002491 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2492 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2493 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2494 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002495 }
2496 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002497}
2498
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002499static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002500 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002501 const Selector &Sel,
2502 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002503
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002504 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002505 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002506 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002507 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002508
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002509 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2510 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002511 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002512 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002513 return D;
2514 }
2515 return 0;
2516}
2517
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002518static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002519 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002520 const Selector &Sel,
2521 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002522 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2523 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002524 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002525 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002526 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002527 GDecl = PD;
2528 break;
2529 }
2530 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002531 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002532 GDecl = OMD;
2533 break;
2534 }
2535 }
2536 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002537 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002538 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2539 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002540 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002541 if (GDecl)
2542 return GDecl;
2543 }
2544 }
2545 return GDecl;
2546}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002547
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002548Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002549Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2550 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002551 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2552 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002553 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002554 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2555 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2556
2557 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2558 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2559 //
2560 // T* t;
2561 // t.f;
2562 //
2563 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2564 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2565 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2566 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002567 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002568 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2569 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002570 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002571 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002572 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002573 return ExprError();
2574 }
2575 }
2576
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002577 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2578 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002579 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002580
2581 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2582 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002583 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002584 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2585 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2586 SS.getRange(),
2587 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002588 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589}
2590
2591/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2592/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2593/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2594static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2595 Expr *BaseExpr,
2596 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002597 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002599 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2600 // diagnostics.
2601 if (!BaseExpr)
2602 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002603
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002604 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2605 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002606}
2607
2608// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2609// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2610// type. The restriction here is:
2611//
2612// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2613// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2614// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2615//
2616// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2617// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2618// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2619// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2620bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2621 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002622 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002623 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002624 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2625 if (!BaseRT) {
2626 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2627 // dependent.
2628 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2629 return false;
2630 }
2631 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632
2633 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002634 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2635 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002636 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002637 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002638
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002639 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002640 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2641 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2642 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002643
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002644 if (!DC->isRecord())
2645 continue;
2646
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002648 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002649
2650 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2651 return false;
2652 }
2653
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002654 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002655 return true;
2656}
2657
2658static bool
2659LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2660 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002661 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2662 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002663 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2664 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002665 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 << BaseRange))
2667 return true;
2668
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002669 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2670 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2671 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2672
2673 bool MOUS;
2674 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2675 return false;
2676 }
2677
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002678 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2679 if (SS.isSet()) {
2680 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2681 // nested-name-specifier.
2682 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2683
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002684 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002685 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2686 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2687 return true;
2688 }
2689
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002690 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002691
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002692 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2693 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2694 << DC << SS.getRange();
2695 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002696 }
2697 }
2698
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002699 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2700 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002701
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002702 if (!R.empty())
2703 return false;
2704
2705 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2706 // for typos.
2707 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002708 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002709 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002710 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2711 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2712 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002713 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2714 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002715 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2716 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2717 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002718 return false;
2719 } else {
2720 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002721 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002722 }
2723
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002724 return false;
2725}
2726
2727Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002729 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002730 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002731 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002732 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002733 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2734 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2735
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002736 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2737 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002738 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002739 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2740 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002741 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002742
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002743 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002744
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002745 // Implicit member accesses.
2746 if (!Base) {
2747 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2748 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2749 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2750 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002751 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002752 return ExprError();
2753
2754 // Explicit member accesses.
2755 } else {
2756 OwningExprResult Result =
2757 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002758 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002759
2760 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2761 Owned(Base);
2762 return ExprError();
2763 }
2764
2765 if (Result.get())
2766 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002767
2768 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2769 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770 }
2771
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002772 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002773 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2774 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775}
2776
2777Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002778Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2779 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2780 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002781 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002782 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002783 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2784 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002785 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002786 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002787 if (IsArrow) {
2788 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2789 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2790 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002791 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002792
2793 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2794 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002795 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2796 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2797 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002798
2799 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002800 return ExprError();
2801
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002802 if (R.empty()) {
2803 // Rederive where we looked up.
2804 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2805 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2806 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002807
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002808 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002809 << MemberName << DC
2810 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002811 return ExprError();
2812 }
2813
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002814 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2815 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2816 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2817 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2818 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2819 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2820 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2821 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2822 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2823 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002824 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002825 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002826 return ExprError();
2827
2828 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2829 // result.
2830 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002831 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002832 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002833 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002834 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002835
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002836 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2837 // pick a member.
2838 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2839
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002840 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2841 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2842 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002843 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2844 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002845 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002846 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002847 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848
2849 return Owned(MemExpr);
2850 }
2851
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002852 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002853 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002854 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2855
2856 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2857
2858 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2859 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2860 // error cases.
2861 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2862 return ExprError();
2863
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002864 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2865 if (!BaseExpr) {
2866 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002867 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002868 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002869
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002870 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2871 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2872 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2873 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002874 }
2875
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002876 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2877 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2878 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2879 // explicitly qualified.
2880 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2881 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2882 }
2883
2884 // Check the use of this member.
2885 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2886 Owned(BaseExpr);
2887 return ExprError();
2888 }
2889
2890 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2891 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2892 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002893 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2894 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2896 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2897
2898 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2899 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2900 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2901 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2902 else {
2903 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2904 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2905 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2906
2907 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2908 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2909
2910 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2911 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2912 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2913 }
2914
2915 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002916 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002917 return ExprError();
2918 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002919 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2920 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002921 }
2922
2923 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2924 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2925 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002926 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2928 }
2929
2930 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2931 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2932 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002933 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002934 MemberFn->getType()));
2935 }
2936
2937 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2938 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2939 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002940 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2941 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002942 }
2943
2944 Owned(BaseExpr);
2945
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002946 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002947 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002948 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002949 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2950 else
2951 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2952 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002953
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002954 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2955 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002956 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002957 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002958}
2959
2960/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2961/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2962/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2963/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2964/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2965/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2966/// an ordinary member expression.
2967///
2968/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2969/// fixed for ObjC++.
2970Sema::OwningExprResult
2971Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002972 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002973 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002974 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002975 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002976
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002977 // Perform default conversions.
2978 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002979
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002980 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2982
2983 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2984 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002985
2986 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002987 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002988 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2989 // call, and continue on.
2990 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2991 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2992 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2993 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2994 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002995 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2996 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002997 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2998 ->isRecordType()))) {
2999 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3000 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3001 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003002 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003003
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003004 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003005 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003006 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003007 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003008 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003009 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003010
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003011 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3012 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3013 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3014 }
3015 }
3016 }
3017
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003018 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3019 // use that.
3020 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003021 if (IsArrow) {
3022 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3023 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3024 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003025 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003026 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003027 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3028 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003029 }
3030 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003031 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3032 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3033 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3034 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003035 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003036 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003037 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003038
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003039 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3040 // use that.
3041 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3042 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3043 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3044 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3045 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3046 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3047 }
3048 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003049
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003050 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003051
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003052 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003053 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003054 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3055 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3056 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3057 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3058 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3059 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3060 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3061 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3062 // Check the use of this method.
3063 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3064 return ExprError();
3065 }
3066 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3067 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3068 Selector SetterSel =
3069 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3070 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3071 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3072 if (!Setter) {
3073 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3074 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003075 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003076 }
3077 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3078 if (!Setter)
3079 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003080
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003081 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3082 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003083
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003084 if (Getter || Setter) {
3085 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003086
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003087 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003088 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003089 else
3090 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3091 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3092 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003093 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003094 PType,
3095 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3096 }
3097 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3098 << MemberName << BaseType);
3099 }
3100 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003101
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003102 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3103 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3104 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003105 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003106 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003107
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003108 if (IsArrow) {
3109 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003110 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003111 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3112 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003113 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3114 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3115 // struct MyRecord foo;
3116 // foo->bar
3117 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3118 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3119 // by now.
3120 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3121 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003122 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003123 IsArrow = false;
3124 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003125 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3126 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3127 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003128 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003129 } else {
3130 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3131 // type *foo;
3132 // foo.bar
3133 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3134 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3135 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3136 // the appropriate pointer type
3137 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3138 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3139 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3141 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003142 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003143 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3144 IsArrow = true;
3145 }
3146 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003147 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003148
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003149 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003150 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003151 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003152 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003153 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003154 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003155 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003156
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003157 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3158 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003159 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003160 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003161 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003162 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3163 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3164 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3165 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003166 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3167
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003168 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003169 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003170
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003171 if (!IV) {
3172 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3173 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3174 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003175 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003176 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003177 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003178 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3179 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003180 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3181 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003182 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003183 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003184 } else {
3185 Res.clear();
3186 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003187 }
3188 }
3189
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003190 if (IV) {
3191 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3192 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3193 // error cases.
3194 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3195 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003196
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003197 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3198 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3199 return ExprError();
3200 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3201 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3202 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3203 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3204 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3205 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3206 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3207 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3208 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3209 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3210 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3211 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003212 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003213 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003214 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3215 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003216 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003217 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3218 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003219
3220 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3221 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003222 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003223 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003224 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003225 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3226 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003227 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003228 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003229 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003230
3231 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3232 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003233 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003234 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003235 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003236 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003237 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003238 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003239 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003240 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003241 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3242 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003243 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003244 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003245
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003246 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003247 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003248 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3249 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3250 // Check the use of this declaration
3251 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3252 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003253
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003254 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3255 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3256 }
3257 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3258 // Check the use of this method.
3259 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3260 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003261
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003262 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003263 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003264 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3265 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003266 }
3267 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003268
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003269 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003270 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003271 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003272
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003273 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3274 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003275 if (!IsArrow)
3276 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3277 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003278 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003279
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003280 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003281 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003282 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3283 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003284 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003285 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003286 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003287
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003288 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003289 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003290 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003291 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3292 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003293 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003294 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003295 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003296 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003297
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003298 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3299 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3300
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003301 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003302}
3303
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003304/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3305/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3306/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3307/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3308/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3309///
3310/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3311/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3312/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3313/// only be called
3314/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3315/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3316/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3317Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3318 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3319 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003320 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003321 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003322 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003323 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3324 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3325 return ExprError();
3326
3327 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3328
3329 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003330 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003331 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3332 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003333 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003334
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003335 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003336 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3337
3338 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3339 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3340 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3341
3342 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3343 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3344
3345 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003346 OwningExprResult Result;
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003347 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3348 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003349 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3351 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003352 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003353 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003354 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003355 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3356 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003357
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003358 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3359 Owned(Base);
3360 return ExprError();
3361 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003363 if (Result.get()) {
3364 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3365 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3366 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3367 // call now.
3368 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3369 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003370 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003371
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003372 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003373 }
3374
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003375 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003376 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3377 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003378 }
3379
3380 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003381}
3382
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003383Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3384 FunctionDecl *FD,
3385 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3386 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3387 Diag (CallLoc,
3388 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3389 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003390 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003391 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3392 } else {
3393 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3394 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3395
3396 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003397 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3398 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003399
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003400 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3401 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3402 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3403 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003404
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003405 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003406 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003407 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003408
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003409 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3410 InitializedEntity Entity
3411 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3412 InitializationKind Kind
3413 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3414 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3415 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3416
3417 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003418 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003419 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003420 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003421 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003422
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003423 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003424 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003425 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003426 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003427
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3429 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3430 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003431 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3432 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003433 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3434 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003435 }
3436
3437 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003438 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003439}
3440
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003441/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3442/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3443/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3444/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3445/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3446/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003447bool
3448Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003449 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003450 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003451 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3452 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003453 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003454 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3455 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003456 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003457
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003458 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3459 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3460 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3461 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3462 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003463 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003464 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003465 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 }
3467
3468 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3469 // them.
3470 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3471 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3472 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3473 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003474 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003475 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003476 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3477 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3478 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003479 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003481 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003483 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003484 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003485 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3486 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3487 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3488 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3489 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003490 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003491 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003492 if (Invalid)
3493 return true;
3494 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3495 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3496 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003497
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003498 return false;
3499}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003500
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003501bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3502 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3503 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3504 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3505 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3506 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003507 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003508 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3509 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3510 bool Invalid = false;
3511 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3512 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3513 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3514 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003515 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003516 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003517 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003518
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003519 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003520 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3521 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003522
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003523 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3524 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003525 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003526 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003527 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003528
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003529 // Pass the argument
3530 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3531 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3532 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003533
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003534
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003535 InitializedEntity Entity =
3536 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3537 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3538 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3539 SourceLocation(),
3540 Owned(Arg));
3541 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3542 return true;
3543
3544 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003545 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003546 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003547
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003548 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003549 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003550 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3551 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003552
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003553 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003554 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003555 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003557
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003558 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003559 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003560 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003561 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003562 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003563 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003564 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003565 }
3566 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003567 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003568}
3569
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003570/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003571/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3572/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003573Action::OwningExprResult
3574Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3575 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003576 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003577 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003578
3579 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3580 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003581
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003582 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003583 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003584 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003585
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003587 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3588 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3589 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3590 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3591 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003592 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003593 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3594 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003595
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003596 NumArgs = 0;
3597 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003598
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003599 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3600 RParenLoc));
3601 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003602
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003603 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003604 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003605 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3606 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003607 bool Dependent = false;
3608 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3609 Dependent = true;
3610 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3611 Dependent = true;
3612
3613 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003614 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003615 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3616
3617 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3618 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3619 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3620 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3621
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003622 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3623
3624 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3625 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3626 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3627 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3628 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3629 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3630 // method template.
3631 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003632 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3633 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003634 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003635
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003636 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3637 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003638 }
3639
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003640 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003641 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003642 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003643 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003644 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3645 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003646 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003647
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003648 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003649 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003650 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3651 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003652 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3653 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003654 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003655
3656 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3657 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003658 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3659 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003660
3661 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3662 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003663 TheCall.get(), 0))
3664 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003665
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003666 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003667 RParenLoc))
3668 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003669
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003670 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3671 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003672 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003673 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3674 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003675 }
3676 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003677 }
3678
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003679 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003680 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003681 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003682
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003683 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003684 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3685 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003686 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003687 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003688 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003689
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003690 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3691 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3692 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3693
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003694 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3695}
3696
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003697/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3698/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003699/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3700/// block-pointer type.
3701///
3702/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3703Sema::OwningExprResult
3704Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3705 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3706 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3707 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3708 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3709
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003710 // Promote the function operand.
3711 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3712
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003713 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3714 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003715 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3716 Args, NumArgs,
3717 Context.BoolTy,
3718 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003719
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003720 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3721 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3722 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3723 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003724 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003725 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003726 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3727 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003728 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003729 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003730 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003731 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003732 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003733 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003734 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3735 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3736
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003737 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003738 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003739 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3740 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003741 return ExprError();
3742
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003743 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003744 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003745
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003746 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003747 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003748 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003749 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003750 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003751 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003752
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003753 if (FDecl) {
3754 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3755 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3756 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003757 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003758 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003759 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003760 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3761 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3762 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3763 }
3764 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003765 }
3766
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003767 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003768 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3769 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3770 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003771 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3772 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003773 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3774 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003775 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003776 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003777 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003778 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003779
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003780 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3781 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003782 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3783 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003784
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003785 // Check for sentinels
3786 if (NDecl)
3787 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003788
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003789 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003790 if (FDecl) {
3791 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3792 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003793
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003794 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003795 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3796 } else if (NDecl) {
3797 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3798 return ExprError();
3799 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003800
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003801 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003802}
3803
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003804Action::OwningExprResult
3805Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3806 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003807 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003808 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003809 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003810
3811 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3812 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3813 if (!TInfo)
3814 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3815
3816 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3817}
3818
3819Action::OwningExprResult
3820Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3821 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3822 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003823 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003824
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003825 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003826 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003827 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3828 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003829 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3830 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003831 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003832 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003833 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003834 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003835
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003836 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003837 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003838 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003839 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003840 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003841 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3842 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003843 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003844 &literalType);
3845 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003846 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003847 InitExpr.release();
3848 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003849
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003850 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003851 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003852 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003853 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003854 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003855
3856 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003857
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003858 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003859 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003860}
3861
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003862Action::OwningExprResult
3863Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003864 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3865 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3866 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003867
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003868 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003869 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003870
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003871 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3872 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003873 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003874 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003875}
3876
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003877static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3878 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003879 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003880 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3881
3882 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3883 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003884 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3885 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003886 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003887 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3888 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3889 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003890
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003891 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3892 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3893 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3894 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3895 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3896 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3897 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3898 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003899
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003900 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3901 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3902 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3903 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3904 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3905 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003906
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003907 // FIXME: Assert here.
3908 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3909 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3910}
3911
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003912/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003913bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003914 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003915 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003916 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003917 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003918 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3919 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003920
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003921 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003922
3923 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3924 // type needs to be scalar.
3925 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3926 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003927 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3928 return false;
3929 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003931 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3932 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3933 return true;
3934
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003935 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003936 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003937 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3938 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003939 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003940 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3941 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003942 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003943 return false;
3944 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003945
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003946 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003947 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003948 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003949 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003950 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003951 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003952 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003953 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003954 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3955 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3956 break;
3957 }
3958 }
3959 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3960 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3961 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003962 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003963 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003964 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003965
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003966 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3967 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3968 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3969 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
3971 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003972 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003973 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3974 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003975 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003976 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003977
3978 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003979 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003980
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003981 if (castType->isVectorType())
3982 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3983 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3984 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3985
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003986 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3987 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003988
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003989 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003990 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003991 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003992 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003993 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3994 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3995 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3996 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003997 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003998 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3999 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4000 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004001 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004002
4003 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004004
4005 if (Kind == CastExpr::CK_Unknown || Kind == CastExpr::CK_BitCast)
4006 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4007
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004008 return false;
4009}
4010
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004011bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
4012 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004013 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004014
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004015 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004016 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004017 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004018 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004019 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004020 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004021 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004022 } else
4023 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004024 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004025 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004026
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004027 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004028 return false;
4029}
4030
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004031bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004032 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004033 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004034
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004035 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004036
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004037 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4038 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004039 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4040 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4041 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4042 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004043 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004044 return false;
4045 }
4046
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004047 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004048 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4049 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004050 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4051 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4052 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4053 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004054
4055 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4056 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4057 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004058
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004059 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004060 return false;
4061}
4062
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004063Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004065 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4066 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4067 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004068
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004069 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4070 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4071 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004072 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004073
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004074 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004075 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004076 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004077 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4078 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004079
4080 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4081}
4082
4083Action::OwningExprResult
4084Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4085 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4086 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4087
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004088 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004089 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004090 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004091 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004092 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004093
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004094 Op.release();
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004095 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004096 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004097 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4098 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004099}
4100
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004101/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4102/// of comma binary operators.
4103Action::OwningExprResult
4104Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4105 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4106 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4107 if (!E)
4108 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004109
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00004110 OwningExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004111
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004112 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4113 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4114 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004115
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004116 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4117}
4118
4119Action::OwningExprResult
4120Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4121 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004122 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004123 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004124 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004125 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004126
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004127 // Check for an altivec literal,
4128 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004129 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4130 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4131 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4132 return ExprError();
4133 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004134 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4135 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4136 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4137 }
4138 else
4139 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4140 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004141
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004142 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4143 // then handle it as such.
4144 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004145 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4146 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4147 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4148
4149 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4150 // braces instead of the original commas.
4151 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004152 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4153 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004154 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4155 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004156 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004157 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004158 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004159 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4160 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004161 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004162 }
4163}
4164
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004165Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004166 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004167 MultiExprArg Val,
4168 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004169 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4170 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004171 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4172 Expr *expr;
4173 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4174 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4175 else
4176 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004177 return Owned(expr);
4178}
4179
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004180/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4181/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004182/// C99 6.5.15
4183QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4184 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004185 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4186 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4187 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4188
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004189 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4190 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4191 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4192 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4193 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4194 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004195
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004196 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004197 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4198 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4199 << CondTy;
4200 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004201 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004202
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004203 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004204 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4205 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004206
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004207 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4208 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004209 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4210 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4211 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004212 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004213
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004214 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4215 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004216 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4217 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004218 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004219 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004220 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004221 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004222 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004223 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004224
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004225 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004226 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004227 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4228 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4229 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4230 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4231 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4232 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4233 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004234 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4235 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004236 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004237 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004238 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4239 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004240 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004241 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004242 // promote the null to a pointer.
4243 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004244 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004245 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004246 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004247 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004249 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004250 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004251
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004252 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4253 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4254 QuestionLoc);
4255 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4256 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004257
4258
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004259 // Handle block pointer types.
4260 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4261 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4262 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4263 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004264 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4265 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004266 return destType;
4267 }
4268 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004269 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004270 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004271 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004272 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4273 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4274 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004275 return LHSTy;
4276 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004277 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004278 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4279 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004280
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004281 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4282 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004283 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004284 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004285 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4286 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4287 // to get a consistent AST.
4288 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004289 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4290 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004291 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004292 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004293 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004294 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4295 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004296 return LHSTy;
4297 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004298
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004299 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4300 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4301 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004302 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4303 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004304
4305 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4306 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4307 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004308 QualType destPointee
4309 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004310 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004311 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4312 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4313 // Promote to void*.
4314 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004315 return destType;
4316 }
4317 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004318 QualType destPointee
4319 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004320 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004321 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004322 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004323 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004324 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004325 return destType;
4326 }
4327
4328 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4329 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4330 return LHSTy;
4331 }
4332 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4333 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4334 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4335 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4336 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4337 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4338 // to get a consistent AST.
4339 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004340 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4341 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004342 return incompatTy;
4343 }
4344 // The pointer types are compatible.
4345 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4346 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4347 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4348 // type.
4349 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4350 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004351 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4352 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004353 return LHSTy;
4354 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004355
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004356 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4357 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4358 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4359 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004360 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004361 return RHSTy;
4362 }
4363 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4364 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4365 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004366 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004367 return LHSTy;
4368 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004369
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004370 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004371 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4372 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004373 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004374}
4375
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004376/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4377/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4378QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4379 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4380 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4381 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004382
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004383 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4384 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4385 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4386 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4387 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4388 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4389 return LHSTy;
4390 }
4391 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4392 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4394 return RHSTy;
4395 }
4396 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4397 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4398 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4399 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4400 return LHSTy;
4401 }
4402 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4403 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4404 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4405 return RHSTy;
4406 }
4407 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4408 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4409 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4410 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4411 return LHSTy;
4412 }
4413 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4414 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4415 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4416 return RHSTy;
4417 }
4418 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4419 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004420
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004421 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4422 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4423 return LHSTy;
4424 }
4425 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4426 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4427 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004428
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004429 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4430 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4431 // type. This allows
4432 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4433 // where B is a subclass of A.
4434 //
4435 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4436 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4437 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4438 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004439
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004440 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4441 // It could return the composite type.
4442 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4443 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4444 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4445 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4446 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4447 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4448 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4449 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4450 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4451 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4452 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4453 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4454 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4455 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004456 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004457 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4458 ;
4459 else {
4460 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4461 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4462 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4463 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4464 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4465 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4466 return incompatTy;
4467 }
4468 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4469 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4470 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4471 return compositeType;
4472 }
4473 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4474 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4475 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4476 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4477 QualType destPointee
4478 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4479 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4480 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4481 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4482 // Promote to void*.
4483 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4484 return destType;
4485 }
4486 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4487 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4488 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4489 QualType destPointee
4490 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4491 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4492 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4493 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4494 // Promote to void*.
4495 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4496 return destType;
4497 }
4498 return QualType();
4499}
4500
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004501/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004502/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004503Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4504 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4505 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4506 ExprArg RHS) {
4507 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4508 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004509
4510 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4511 // was the condition.
4512 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4513 if (isLHSNull)
4514 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004515
4516 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004517 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004518 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004519 return ExprError();
4520
4521 Cond.release();
4522 LHS.release();
4523 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004524 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004525 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004526 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004527}
4528
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004529// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004530// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004531// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4532// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4533// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004535Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004536 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004537
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004538 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4539 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4540 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4541 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4542 return Compatible;
4543 }
4544
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004545 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004546 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4547 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004549 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004550 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4551 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004552
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004553 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004554
4555 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4556 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4557 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004558 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004559 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004560 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004561
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004562 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4563 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004564 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004565 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004566 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004567 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004568
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004569 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004570 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4571 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004572 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004573
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004574 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004575 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004576 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004577
4578 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004579 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4580 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004581 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004582 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004583 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004584 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4585 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4586 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4587 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4588 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4589 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004590 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004591 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004592 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004593 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004594
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004595 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004596 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004597 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004598 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004599
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004600 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4601 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4602 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4603 // warning can be disabled.
4604 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4605 return ConvTy;
4606 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4607 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004608
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004609 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4610 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4611 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4612 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4613 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4614 do {
4615 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4616 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004617
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004618 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4619 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4620 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004621
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004622 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004623 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004624 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004625
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004626 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004627 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004628 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004629 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004630}
4631
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004632/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4633/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4634/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4635// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004636Sema::AssignConvertType
4637Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004638 QualType rhsType) {
4639 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004640
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004641 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004642 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4643 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004645 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4646 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4647 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004648
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004649 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004650
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004651 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004652 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004653 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004654
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004655 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4656 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4657 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4658 }
4659 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004660 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004661 return ConvTy;
4662}
4663
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004664/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4665/// for assignment compatibility.
4666Sema::AssignConvertType
4667Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004668 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4669 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004670 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4671 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004672 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004673 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004674 }
4675 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4676 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004677 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4678 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004679 return IncompatiblePointer;
4680 return Compatible;
4681 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004682 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004683 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004684 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004685 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4686 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4687 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4688 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4689 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4690 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004691
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004692 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4693 return Compatible;
4694 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4695 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004696 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004697}
4698
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004699/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4700/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004701/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4702///
4703/// int a, *pint;
4704/// short *pshort;
4705/// struct foo *pfoo;
4706///
4707/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4708/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4709/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4710/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4711///
4712/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004713/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004714///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004715Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004716Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004717 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4718 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004719 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4720 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004721
4722 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004723 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004724
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004725 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4726 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4727 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4728 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4729 return Compatible;
4730 }
4731
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004732 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4733 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4734 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4735 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4736 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4737 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4738 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004739 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004740 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004741 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004742 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004743 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004744 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4745 // to the same ExtVector type.
4746 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4747 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4748 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004749 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004750 return Compatible;
4751 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004752
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004753 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004754 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4755 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4756 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4757 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4758 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4759 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004760 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004761
4762 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4763 // vector type and vice versa
4764 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4765 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004766 }
4767 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004768 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004769
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004770 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4771 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004772 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004773
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004774 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004775 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004776 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004777
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004778 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004779 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004780
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004781 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004782 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004783 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4784 return Compatible;
4785 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004786 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004787 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4788 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004789 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004790
4791 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004792 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004793 return Compatible;
4794 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004795 return Incompatible;
4796 }
4797
4798 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4799 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004800 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004801
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004802 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004803 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004804 return Compatible;
4805
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004806 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4807 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004808
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004809 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004810 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004811 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004812 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004813 return Incompatible;
4814 }
4815
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004816 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4817 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4818 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004819
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004820 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004821 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004822 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4823 return Compatible;
4824 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004825 }
4826 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004827 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004828 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004829 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004830 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4831 return Compatible;
4832 }
4833 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4834 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4835 return Compatible;
4836 return Incompatible;
4837 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004838 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004839 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004840 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4841 return Compatible;
4842
4843 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004844 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004845
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004846 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004847 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004848
4849 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004850 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004851 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004852 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004853 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004854 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4855 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4856 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4857 return Compatible;
4858
4859 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4860 return PointerToInt;
4861
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004862 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004863 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004864 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4865 return Compatible;
4866 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004867 }
4868 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004869 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004870 return Compatible;
4871 return Incompatible;
4872 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004873
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004874 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004875 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004876 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004877 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004878 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004879}
4880
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004881/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4882/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004883static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004884 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4885 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4886 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004887 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004888 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004889 SourceLocation());
4890 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4891 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4892
4893 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4894 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004895 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004896 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004897 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004898}
4899
4900Sema::AssignConvertType
4901Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4902 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4903
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004904 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004905 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4906 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004907 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004908 return Incompatible;
4909
4910 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4911 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4912 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4913 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004914 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4915 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004916 it != itend; ++it) {
4917 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4918 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4919 // 1) void pointer
4920 // 2) null pointer constant
4921 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004922 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004923 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004924 InitField = *it;
4925 break;
4926 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004927
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004928 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004929 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004930 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004931 InitField = *it;
4932 break;
4933 }
4934 }
4935
4936 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4937 == Compatible) {
4938 InitField = *it;
4939 break;
4940 }
4941 }
4942
4943 if (!InitField)
4944 return Incompatible;
4945
4946 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4947 return Compatible;
4948}
4949
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004950Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004951Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004952 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4953 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4954 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4955 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4956 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004957 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004958 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004959 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004960 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004961 }
4962
4963 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4964 // structures.
4965 }
4966
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004967 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4968 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004969 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4970 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004971 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004972 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004973 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004974 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004975 return Compatible;
4976 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004977
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004978 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004979 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004980 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004981 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004982 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004984 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004985 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004986
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004987 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4988 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004989
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004990 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4991 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004992 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4993 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4994 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4995 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004996 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004997 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004998 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004999 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005000}
5001
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005002QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005003 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005004 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005005 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005006 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005007}
5008
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005009QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005010 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005011 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005012 QualType lhsType =
5013 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5014 QualType rhsType =
5015 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005016
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005017 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005018 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005019 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005020
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005021 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5022 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005023 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5024 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005025 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5026 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005027 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005028 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005029 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5030 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5031 return lhsType;
5032 }
5033
5034 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5035 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005036 }
5037 }
5038 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005039
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005040 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5041 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5042 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5043 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5044 return rhsType;
5045 }
5046
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005047 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5048 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5049 bool swapped = false;
5050 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5051 swapped = true;
5052 std::swap(rex, lex);
5053 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5054 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005055
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005056 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005057 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005058 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005059 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005060 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005061 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005062 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5063 return lhsType;
5064 }
5065 }
5066 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5067 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5068 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005069 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005070 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5071 return lhsType;
5072 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005073 }
5074 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005075
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005076 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005077 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005078 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005079 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005080 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005081}
5082
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005083QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5084 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005085 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005086 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005087
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005088 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005089
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005090 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5091 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5092 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005093
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005094 // Check for division by zero.
5095 if (isDiv &&
5096 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005097 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005098 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005099
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005100 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005101}
5102
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005103QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005104 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005105 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005106 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5107 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005108 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5109 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5110 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005111
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005112 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005113
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005114 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5115 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005116
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005117 // Check for remainder by zero.
5118 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005119 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5120 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005121
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005122 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005123}
5124
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005125QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005126 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005127 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5128 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5129 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5130 return compType;
5131 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005132
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005133 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005134
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005135 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005136 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5137 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5138 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005139 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005140 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005141
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005142 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5143 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005144 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005145 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5146
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005147 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005148
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005149 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005150 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005151
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005152 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5153 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005154 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5155 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005156 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005157 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005158 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005159
5160 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5161 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5162 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005163 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005164 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5165 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5166 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5167 return QualType();
5168 }
5169
5170 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5171 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5172 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005173 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005174 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005175 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005176 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005177 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5178 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005179 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5180 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005181 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005182 return QualType();
5183 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005184 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005185 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005186 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5187 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5188 return QualType();
5189 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005190
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005191 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005192 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5193 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5194 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5195 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5196 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005197 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005198 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5199 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005200 return PExp->getType();
5201 }
5202 }
5203
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005204 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005205}
5206
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005207// C99 6.5.6
5208QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005209 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5210 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5211 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5212 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5213 return compType;
5214 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005215
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005216 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005217
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005218 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005219
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005220 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005221 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5222 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005223 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005224 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005225 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005226
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005227 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005228 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005229 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005230
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005231 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005232
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005233 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5234 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5235 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5236 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5237 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5238 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5239 return QualType();
5240 }
5241
5242 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5243 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5244 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5245 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5246 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005247 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005248 return QualType();
5249 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005250
5251 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5252 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5253 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005254 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005255 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005256 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005257 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005258 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005259
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005260 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005261 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005262 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5263 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5264 return QualType();
5265 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005266
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005267 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005268 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5269 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5270 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5271 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5272 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5273 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005274 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005275 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5276
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005277 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005278 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005279 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005280
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005281 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005282 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005283 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005284
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005285 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5286 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5287 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5288 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5289 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5290 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5291 return QualType();
5292 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005293
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005294 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5295 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5296 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5297 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005298 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005299 return QualType();
5300 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005301
5302 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5303 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5304 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5305 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5306 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005307 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5308 << rex->getSourceRange()
5309 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005310 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005311
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005312 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5313 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5314 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5315 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5316 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5317 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5318 return QualType();
5319 }
5320 } else {
5321 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5322 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5323 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5324 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5325 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5326 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5327 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5328 return QualType();
5329 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005330 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005331
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005332 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5333 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5334 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5335 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5336 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005337 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005338 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005339
5340 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005341 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5342 }
5343 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005344
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005345 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005346}
5347
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005348// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005349QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005350 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005351 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005352 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5353 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005354 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005355
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005356 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5357 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5358 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5359
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005360 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5361 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005362 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5363 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5364 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5365 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5366 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005367 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005368 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005369 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005370
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005371 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005372
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005373 // Sanity-check shift operands
5374 llvm::APSInt Right;
5375 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005376 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5377 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005378 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005379 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5380 else {
5381 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5382 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5383 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5384 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5385 }
5386 }
5387
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005388 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005389 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005390}
5391
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005392static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5393 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5394 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5395 return true;
5396 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5397 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5398 }
5399 return false;
5400}
5401
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005402// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005403QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005404 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5405 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5406
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005407 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005408 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005409 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005410
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005411 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5412 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005413
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005414 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5415 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005416 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5417 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5418 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005419 //
5420 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5421 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5422 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5423 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5424 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5425 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005426 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5427 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005428 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005429 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005430 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005431 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005432 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5433 << 0 // self-
5434 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5435 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5436 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5437 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5438 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5439 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5440 // what is it always going to eval to?
5441 char always_evals_to;
5442 switch(Opc) {
5443 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5444 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5445 break;
5446 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5447 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5448 break;
5449 default:
5450 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5451 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5452 break;
5453 }
5454 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5455 << 1 // array
5456 << always_evals_to);
5457 }
5458 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005459 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005460
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005461 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5462 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5463 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5464 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005465
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005466 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5467 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005468 Expr *literalString = 0;
5469 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005470 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005471 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005472 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005473 literalString = lex;
5474 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005475 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5476 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005477 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005478 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005479 literalString = rex;
5480 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5481 }
5482
5483 if (literalString) {
5484 std::string resultComparison;
5485 switch (Opc) {
5486 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5487 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5488 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5489 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5490 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5491 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5492 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5493 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005494
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005495 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5496 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5497 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005498 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005499 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005500 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005501
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005502 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5503 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5504 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5505 else {
5506 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5507 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5508 }
5509
5510 lType = lex->getType();
5511 rType = rex->getType();
5512
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005513 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005514 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005515
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005516 if (isRelational) {
5517 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005518 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005519 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005520 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005521 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005522 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005523
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005524 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005525 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005526 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005527
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005528 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005529 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005530 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005531 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005532
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005533 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5534 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005535 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005536 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005537 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005538 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005539 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005540
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005541 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005542 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5543 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005544 if (!isRelational &&
5545 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5546 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5547 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005548 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5549 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005550 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5551 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005552 Diag(Loc,
5553 isSFINAEContext()?
5554 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5555 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005556 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005557
5558 if (isSFINAEContext())
5559 return QualType();
5560
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005561 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5562 return ResultTy;
5563 }
5564 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005565 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5566 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5567 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5568 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5569 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5570 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005571 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005572 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005573 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005574 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005575 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005576 if (T.isNull()) {
5577 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5578 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5579 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005580 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005581 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005582 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005583 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005584 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005585 }
5586
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005587 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5588 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005589 return ResultTy;
5590 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005591 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5592 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5593 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5594 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5595 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5596 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5597 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5598 }
5599 } else if (!isRelational &&
5600 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5601 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5602 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5603 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5604 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5605 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5606 }
5607 } else {
5608 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005609 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005610 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005611 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005612 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005613 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005614 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005615 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005616
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005617 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005618 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005619 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005620 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005621 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5622 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005623 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5624 lType->isMemberPointerType()
5625 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5626 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005627 return ResultTy;
5628 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005629 if (LHSIsNull &&
5630 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5631 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005632 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5633 rType->isMemberPointerType()
5634 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5635 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005636 return ResultTy;
5637 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005638
5639 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005640 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005641 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5642 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005643 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5644 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5645 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5646 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5647 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5648 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5649 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5650 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005651 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005652 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005653 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005654 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005655 if (T.isNull()) {
5656 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005657 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005658 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005659 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005660 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005661 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005662 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005663 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005664 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005665
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005666 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5667 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005668 return ResultTy;
5669 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005670
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005671 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005672 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5673 return ResultTy;
5674 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005675
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005676 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005677 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005678 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5679 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005680
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005681 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005682 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005683 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005684 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005685 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005686 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005687 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005688 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005689 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005690 if (!isRelational
5691 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5692 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005693 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005694 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005695 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005696 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005697 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5698 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5699 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005700 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005701 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005702 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005703 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005704
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005705 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005706 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005707 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5708 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005709 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005710 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005711 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005712 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005713
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005714 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5715 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005716 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005717 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005718 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005719 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005720 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005721 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005722 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005723 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005724 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5725 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005726 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005727 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005728 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005729 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005730 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5731 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005732 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005733 bool isError = false;
5734 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5735 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5736 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005737 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005738 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005739 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005740 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5741 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5742 isError = true;
5743 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005744 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005745
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005746 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005747 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005748 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005749 if (isError)
5750 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005751 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005752
5753 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5754 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005755 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005756 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005757 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005758 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005759
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005760 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005761 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5762 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005763 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005764 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005765 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005766 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5767 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005768 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005769 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005770 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005771 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005772}
5773
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005775/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005776/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5777/// types.
5778QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005779 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005780 bool isRelational) {
5781 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5782 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005783 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005784 if (vType.isNull())
5785 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005786
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005787 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5788 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005789
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005790 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5791 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5792 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005793 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005794 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5795 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5796 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005797 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5798 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5799 << 0 // self-
5800 << 2 // "a constant"
5801 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005802 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005803
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005804 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005805 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5806 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005807 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005808 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005809
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005810 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5811 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5812 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005813 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005814 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005815
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005816 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005817 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005818 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005819 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005820 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005821 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5822
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005823 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005824 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005825 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5826}
5827
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005828inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005829 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005830 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5831 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5832 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5833 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5834
5835 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5836 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005837
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005838 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005839
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005840 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005841 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005842 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005843}
5844
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005845inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005846 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5847
5848 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5849 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5850 // is a constant.
5851 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005852 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005853 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005854 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5855 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5856 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5857 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5858 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5859 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5860 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5861 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5862 << rex->getSourceRange()
5863 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5864 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5865 }
5866 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005867
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005868 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5869 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5870 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005871
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005872 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5873 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005874
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005875 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005876 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005877
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005878 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5879 // non-overloadable operands.
5880
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005881 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5882 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005883 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5884 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5885 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005886 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005887
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005888 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5889 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5890 // The result is a bool.
5891 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005892}
5893
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005894/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5895/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5896/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5897///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005898static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005899 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5900 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5901 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5902 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005903 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005904 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5905 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5906 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5907 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005908 }
5909 }
5910 return false;
5911}
5912
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005913/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5914/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5915static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005916 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005917 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005918 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005919 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5920 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005921 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5922 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005923
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005924 unsigned Diag = 0;
5925 bool NeedType = false;
5926 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005927 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005928 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005929 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5930 NeedType = true;
5931 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005932 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005933 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5934 NeedType = true;
5935 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005936 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005937 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5938 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005939 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5940 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005941 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005942 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5943 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005944 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5945 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005946 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5947 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005948 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005949 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005950 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005951 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005952 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5953 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005954 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005955 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5956 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005957 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5958 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5959 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005960 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5961 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5962 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005963 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5964 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5965 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005966 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005967
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005968 SourceRange Assign;
5969 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5970 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005971 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005972 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005973 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005974 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005975 return true;
5976}
5977
5978
5979
5980// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005981QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5982 SourceLocation Loc,
5983 QualType CompoundType) {
5984 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5985 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005986 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005987
5988 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5989 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005990 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005991 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005992 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005993 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005994 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5995 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5996 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5997 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5998 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5999 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6000 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6001 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6002 }
6003 }
6004
6005 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006006 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6007 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6008 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006009 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006010 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006011 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006012 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006013
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006014 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6015 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6016 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006017 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006018 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6019 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6020 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
6021 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
6022 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006023 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006024 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006025 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6026 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6027 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006028 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6029 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006030 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
6031 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
6032 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006033 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006034 }
6035 } else {
6036 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006037 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006038 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006039
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006040 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006041 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006042 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006043
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006044
6045 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6046 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6047 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6048 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6049 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6050 // check.
6051 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6052 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6053 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6054 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6055 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6056 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6057 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6058 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6059 }
6060
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006061 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6062 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006063 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006064 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6065 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006066 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006067 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006068 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006069}
6070
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006071// C99 6.5.17
6072QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006073 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6074
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006075 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006076 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6077 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6078 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006079
6080 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6081 // incomplete in C++).
6082
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006083 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006084}
6085
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006086/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6087/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006088QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006089 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006090 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6091 return Context.DependentTy;
6092
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006093 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6094 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006095
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006096 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6097 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6098 if (!isInc) {
6099 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6100 return QualType();
6101 }
6102 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6103 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6104 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006105 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006106 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6107 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006108
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006109 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006110 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006111 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6112 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6113 << Op->getSourceRange();
6114 return QualType();
6115 }
6116
6117 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006119 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006120 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6121 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6122 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6123 return QualType();
6124 }
6125
6126 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006127 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006128 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006129 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006130 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006131 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006132 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006133 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006134 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006135 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6136 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6137 return QualType();
6138 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006139 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006140 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6141 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006142 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006143 } else {
6144 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006145 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006146 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006147 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006148 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006149 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006150 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006151 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006152 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6153 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6154 // operand.
6155 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6156 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006157}
6158
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006159/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006160/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006161/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6162/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6163/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6164/// - &(x) => x
6165/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6166/// - &s.xx => s
6167/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6168/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6169/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6170/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006171static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006172 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006173 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006174 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006175 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006176 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6177 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6178 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006179 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006180 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006181 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006182 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006183 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006184 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6185 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006186 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6187 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6188 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6189 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6190 }
6191 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006192 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006193 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6194 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006195
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006196 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006197 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6198 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6199 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6200 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6201 default:
6202 return 0;
6203 }
6204 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006205 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006206 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006207 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006208 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6209 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006210 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006211 default:
6212 return 0;
6213 }
6214}
6215
6216/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006217/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006218/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006219/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006220/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006221/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006222/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006223QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006224 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6225 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6226
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006227 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6228 return Context.DependentTy;
6229
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006230 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6231 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6232 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6233 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6234 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6235 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6236 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6237 }
6238 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6239 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6240 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006241 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006242 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006243
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006244 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6245 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6246 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6247 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6248 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6249 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6250 // branch of the if, below.
6251 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6252 << dcl;
6253 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6254
6255 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6256 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6257 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6258 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006259 }
6260
6261 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006262 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6263 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6264 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6265 if (isSFINAEContext())
6266 return QualType();
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006267 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006268 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006269 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006270 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006271 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006272 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006273 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006274 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6275 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006276 return QualType();
6277 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006278 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006279 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6280 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6281 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006282 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006283 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006284 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006285 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006286 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006287 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006288 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6289 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6290 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6291 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6292 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006293 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6294 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006295 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6296 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006297 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6298 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006299 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006300 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006301 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6302 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006303 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006304 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6305 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006306 return QualType();
6307 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006308 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006309 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006310 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006311 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006312 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6313 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006314 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006315 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006316 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6317 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006318 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006319 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6320 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6321 return QualType();
6322 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006323
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006324 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6325 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006326 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006327 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006328 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006329 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006330 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006331 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6332 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006333 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6334 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6335 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006336 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006337 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006338
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006339 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6340 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6341 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6342 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6343 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6344 }
6345
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006346 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006347 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6348 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006349 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006350}
6351
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006352/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006353QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006354 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6355 return Context.DependentTy;
6356
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006357 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006358 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6359 QualType Result;
6360
6361 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6362 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6363 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6364 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6365 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6366 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6367 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6368 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6369 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006370
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006371 if (Result.isNull()) {
6372 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6373 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6374 return QualType();
6375 }
6376
6377 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006378}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006379
6380static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6381 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6382 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6383 switch (Kind) {
6384 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006385 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6386 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006387 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6388 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6389 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6390 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6391 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6392 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6393 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6394 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6395 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6396 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6397 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6398 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6399 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6400 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6401 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6402 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6403 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6404 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6405 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6406 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6407 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6408 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6409 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6410 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6411 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6412 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6413 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6414 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6415 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6416 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6417 }
6418 return Opc;
6419}
6420
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006421static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6422 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6423 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6424 switch (Kind) {
6425 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6426 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6427 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6428 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6429 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6430 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6431 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6432 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6433 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006434 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6435 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006436 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006437 }
6438 return Opc;
6439}
6440
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006441/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6442/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6443/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006444Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6445 unsigned Op,
6446 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006447 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006448 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006449 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6450 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6451 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006452
6453 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006454 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6455 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6456 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006457 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6458 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6459 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6460 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6461 break;
6462 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006463 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006464 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6465 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006466 break;
6467 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6468 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6469 break;
6470 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6471 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6472 break;
6473 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6474 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6475 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006476 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006477 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6478 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6479 break;
6480 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6481 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6482 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6483 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006484 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006485 break;
6486 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6487 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006488 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006489 break;
6490 case BinaryOperator::And:
6491 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6492 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6493 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6494 break;
6495 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6496 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006497 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006498 break;
6499 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6500 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006501 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6502 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006503 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6504 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6505 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006506 break;
6507 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006508 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6509 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6510 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6511 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006512 break;
6513 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006514 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6515 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6516 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006517 break;
6518 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006519 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6520 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6521 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006522 break;
6523 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6524 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006525 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6526 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6527 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6528 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006529 break;
6530 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6531 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6532 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006533 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6534 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6535 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6536 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006537 break;
6538 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6539 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6540 break;
6541 }
6542 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006543 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006544 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
6545 if (Opc >= BinaryOperator::Assign && Opc <= BinaryOperator::OrAssign)
6546 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6547 << ResultTy;
6548 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006549 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006550 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6551 else
6552 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006553 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6554 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006555}
6556
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006557/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6558/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006559static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6560 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006561 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6562 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6563 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006564 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006565 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6566
6567 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6568 return;
6569
6570 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6571 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6572 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006573 return;
6574 }
6575
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006576 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6577 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006578 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006579
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006580 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006581 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006582
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006583 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6584 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6585 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6586 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006587 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006588 return;
6589 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006590
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006591 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006592 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6593 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006594}
6595
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006596/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6597/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6598/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6599/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006600static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6601 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006602 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6603 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6604 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6605 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006606 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006607 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006608 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6609
6610 // Subs are not binary operators.
6611 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6612 return;
6613
6614 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6615 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006616 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6617 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006618 return;
6619
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006620 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006621 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006622 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006623 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6624 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006625 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006626 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006627 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6628 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6629 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6630 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006631 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006632 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006633 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006634 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6635 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006636 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006637 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006638 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6639 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6640 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6641 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006642}
6643
6644/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6645/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6646/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6647static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6648 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006649 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006650 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6651}
6652
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006653// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006654Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6655 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6656 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006657 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006658 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006659
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006660 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6661 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006662
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006663 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6664 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6665
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006666 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6667}
6668
6669Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6670 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6671 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006672 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006673 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006674 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6675 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6676 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6677 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6678 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006679 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006680 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006681 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6682 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6683 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006684
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006685 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6686 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006687 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006688 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006689
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006690 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006691 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006692}
6693
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006694Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006695 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006696 ExprArg InputArg) {
6697 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006698
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006699 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006700 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006701 QualType resultType;
6702 switch (Opc) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006703 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6704 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006705 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6706 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006707 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006708 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006709 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6710 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6711 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006712 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006713 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006714 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006715 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006716 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006717 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006718 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006719 break;
6720 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6721 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006722 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6723 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006724 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6725 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006726 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6727 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006728 break;
6729 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6730 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6731 break;
6732 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6733 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6734 resultType->isPointerType())
6735 break;
6736
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006737 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6738 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006739 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006740 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6741 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006742 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6743 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006744 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6745 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6746 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006747 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006748 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006749 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006750 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6751 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006752 break;
6753 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006754 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006755 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006756 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006757 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6758 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006759 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006760 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6761 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006762 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006763 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6764 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006765 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006766 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006767 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006768 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006769 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006770 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006771 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006772 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006773 }
6774 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006775 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006776
6777 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006778 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006779}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006780
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006781Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6782 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6783 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006784 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006785 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6786 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006787 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6788 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6789 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6790 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006791 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006792 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006793 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6794 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6795 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006796
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006797 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6798 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006799
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006800 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6801}
6802
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006803// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6804Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6805 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6806 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6807}
6808
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006809/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006810Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6811 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6812 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006813 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006814 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006815
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006816 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6817 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006818 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006819 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006820
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006821 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006822 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6823 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006824}
6825
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006826Sema::OwningExprResult
6827Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6828 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6829 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006830 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6831 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6832
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006833 bool isFileScope
6834 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006835 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006836 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006837
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006838 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6839 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6840 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006841
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006842 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6843 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6844 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006845
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006846 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6847 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6848 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6849 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6850 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006851
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006852 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006853 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006854 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006855
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006856 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6857 // expressions are not lvalues.
6858
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006859 substmt.release();
6860 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006861}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006862
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006863Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6864 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006865 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6866 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006867 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6868 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006869 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006870 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006871
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006872 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6873 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6874 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006875 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006876 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6877 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6878
6879 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6880 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6881 if (!Dependent
6882 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6883 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6884 << TypeRange))
6885 return ExprError();
6886
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006887 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6888 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006889 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6890 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006891 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006892 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6893 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006894
6895 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6896 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6897 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6898 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6899 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6900 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6901 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6902 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6903 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6904 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6905 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6906 if(!AT)
6907 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6908 << CurrentType);
6909 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6910 } else
6911 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6912
6913 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6914 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6915 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6916 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6917 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6918 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6919 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6920 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6921
6922 // Record this array index.
6923 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6924 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6925 continue;
6926 }
6927
6928 // Offset of a field.
6929 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6930 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6931 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6932 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6933 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6934 continue;
6935 }
6936
6937 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6938 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6939 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6940 return ExprError();
6941
6942 // Look for the designated field.
6943 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6944 if (!RC)
6945 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6946 << CurrentType);
6947 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6948
6949 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6950 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6951 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6952 // (clause 9).
6953 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6954 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6955 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6956 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6957 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6958 << CurrentType))
6959 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6960 }
6961
6962 // Look for the field.
6963 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6964 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6965 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6966 if (!MemberDecl)
6967 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6968 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6969 OC.LocEnd));
6970
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006971 // C99 7.17p3:
6972 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6973 //
6974 // We diagnose this as an error.
6975 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6976 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6977 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6978 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6979 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6980 return ExprError();
6981 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006982
6983 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6984 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6985 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6986 do {
6987 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6988 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6989 }
6990
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006991 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6992 // the base class indirections.
6993 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6994 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006995 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006996 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6997 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6998 B != BEnd; ++B)
6999 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7000 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007001
7002 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007003 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7004 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7005 unsigned n = Path.size();
7006 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7007 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7008 } else {
7009 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7010 }
7011 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7012 }
7013
7014 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7015 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7016 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7017}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007018
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007019Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
7020 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7021 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7022 TypeTy *argty,
7023 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7024 unsigned NumComponents,
7025 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7026
7027 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7028 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7029 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7030 return ExprError();
7031
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007032 if (!ArgTInfo)
7033 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7034
7035 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7036 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007037}
7038
7039
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007040Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7041 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7042 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007043 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7044 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7045 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7046 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007047
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007048 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007049
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007050 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7051}
7052
7053Sema::OwningExprResult
7054Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7055 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7056 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7057 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007058 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7059 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7060 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7061 return ExprError();
7062 }
7063
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007064 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007065 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007066}
7067
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007068
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007069Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7070 ExprArg cond,
7071 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7072 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7073 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7074 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7075 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007076
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007077 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7078
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007079 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007080 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007081 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007082 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007083 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007084 } else {
7085 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7086 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7087 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7088 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007089 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7090 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7091 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007092
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007093 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7094 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007095 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7096 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007097 }
7098
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007099 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7100 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007101 resType, RPLoc,
7102 resType->isDependentType(),
7103 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007104}
7105
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007106//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7107// Clang Extensions.
7108//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7109
7110/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007111void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007112 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7113 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7114 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007115 if (BlockScope)
7116 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7117 else
7118 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007119}
7120
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007121void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007122 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007123 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007124
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007125 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007126 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007127 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007128
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007129 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007130 QualType RetTy;
7131 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007132 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007133 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007134 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007135 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7136 } else {
7137 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007139 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007140
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007141 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007142
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007143 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7144 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7145 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007146 return;
7147 }
7148
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007149 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7150 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7151 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7152 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7153 return;
7154 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007155
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007156 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007157 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7158 // ^ * { ... }
7159 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007160 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7161 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007162
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007163 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007164 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007165 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7166 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7167 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7168 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007169 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7170 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7171 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7172 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7173 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007174 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007175 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007176
7177 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7178 // ^ fntype { ... }
7179 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7180 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7181 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7182 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7183 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7184 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7185 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007186 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007187 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007188 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007189
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007190 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7191 if (!Params.empty())
7192 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007193
7194 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007195 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007196
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007197 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007198 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7199 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7200 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7201 }
7202
7203 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7204 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007205 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007206 return;
7207
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007208 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7209 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7210
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007211 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007212 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7213 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7214
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007215 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007216 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7217 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7218 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7219
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007220 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007221 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007222 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007223}
7224
7225/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7226/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7227void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007228 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007229 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007230 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007231 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007232}
7233
7234/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7235/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007236Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7237 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007238 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7239 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7240 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007241
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007242 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007243
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007244 PopDeclContext();
7245
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007246 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007247 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7248 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007249
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007250 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007251 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007252
7253 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7254 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7255 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7256
7257 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7258 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7259
7260 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7261 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7262 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7263 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7264
7265 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7266 // preserve its sugar structure.
7267 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7268 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7269 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7270
7271 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7272 } else {
7273 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7274 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7275 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7276 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7277 FPT->isVariadic(),
7278 /*quals*/ 0,
7279 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7280 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7281 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7282 FPT->exception_begin(),
7283 Ext);
7284 }
7285
7286 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7287 } else {
7288 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7289 false, false, 0, 0,
7290 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7291 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007292
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007293 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007294 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7295 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007296 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007297
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007298 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007299 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007300 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007301
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007302 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007303
7304 bool Good = true;
7305 // Check goto/label use.
7306 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7307 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7308 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7309
7310 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7311 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7312 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7313 continue;
7314
7315 // Emit error.
7316 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7317 Good = false;
7318 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007319 if (!Good) {
7320 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007321 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007322 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007323
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007324 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007325 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7326 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7327 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007328
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007329 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7330 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007331 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007332 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007333}
7334
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007335Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7336 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7337 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007338 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7339 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
7340 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, move(expr), TInfo, RPLoc);
7341}
7342
7343Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7344 ExprArg expr, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7345 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007346 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7347 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007348
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007349 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007350
7351 // Get the va_list type
7352 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007353 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7354 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7355 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7356 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007357 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007358 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7359 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7360 } else {
7361 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7362 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007363 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007364 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007365 return ExprError();
7366 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007367
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007368 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7369 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007370 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7371 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007372 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007373 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007374
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007375 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007376 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007377
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007378 expr.release();
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007379 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7380 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007381}
7382
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007383Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007384 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7385 // pointers on the target.
7386 QualType Ty;
7387 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7388 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7389 else
7390 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7391
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007392 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007393}
7394
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007395static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007396 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007397 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7398 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007399
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007400 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7401 if (!PT)
7402 return;
7403
7404 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7405 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7406 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7407 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7408 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7409 return;
7410 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007411
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007412 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7413 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7414 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7415 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007416
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007417 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007418}
7419
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007420bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7421 SourceLocation Loc,
7422 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007423 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7424 bool *Complained) {
7425 if (Complained)
7426 *Complained = false;
7427
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007428 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7429 bool isInvalid = false;
7430 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007431 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007432
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007433 switch (ConvTy) {
7434 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7435 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007436 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007437 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7438 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007439 case IntToPointer:
7440 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7441 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007442 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007443 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007444 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7445 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007446 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7447 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7448 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007449 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7450 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7451 break;
7452 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007453 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7454 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7455 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7456 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7457 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7458 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7459 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7460 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7461 // C++ semantics.
7462 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7463 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7464 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007465 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7466 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007467 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007468 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007469 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007470 case IntToBlockPointer:
7471 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7472 break;
7473 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007474 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007475 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007476 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007477 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007478 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7479 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7480 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007481 case IncompatibleVectors:
7482 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7483 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007484 case Incompatible:
7485 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7486 isInvalid = true;
7487 break;
7488 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007489
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007490 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7491 switch (Action) {
7492 case AA_Assigning:
7493 case AA_Initializing:
7494 // The destination type comes first.
7495 FirstType = DstType;
7496 SecondType = SrcType;
7497 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007498
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007499 case AA_Returning:
7500 case AA_Passing:
7501 case AA_Converting:
7502 case AA_Sending:
7503 case AA_Casting:
7504 // The source type comes first.
7505 FirstType = SrcType;
7506 SecondType = DstType;
7507 break;
7508 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007509
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007510 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007511 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007512 if (Complained)
7513 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007514 return isInvalid;
7515}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007516
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007517bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007518 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7519 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7520 if (Result)
7521 *Result = ICEResult;
7522 return false;
7523 }
7524
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007525 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7526
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007527 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007528 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7529 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7530
7531 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7532 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7533 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7534 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7535 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7536 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7537 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007538
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007539 return true;
7540 }
7541
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007542 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7543 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007544
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007545 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7546 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7547 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007548
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007549 if (Result)
7550 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7551 return false;
7552}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007553
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007554void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007555Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007556 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7557 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007558}
7559
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007560void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007561Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7562 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7563 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7564 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007565
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007566 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7567 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7568 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7569 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7570 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007571 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007572 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7573 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7574 I != IEnd; ++I)
7575 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7576 }
7577
7578 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7579 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7580 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7581 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7582 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7583 I != IEnd; ++I)
7584 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7585 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007586 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007587
7588 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7589 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7590 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7591 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007592 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007593 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7594 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7595 ExprTemporaries.end());
7596
7597 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7598 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007599}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007600
7601/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7602///
7603/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7604/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7605/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7606/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7607///
7608/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7609///
7610/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7611void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7612 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007613
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007614 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007615 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007616
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007617 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7618 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7619 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7620 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007621 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007622 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007623 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007624 return;
7625 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007626
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007627 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7628 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007630 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7631 // an instantiation.
7632 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7633 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007634
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007635 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007636 case Unevaluated:
7637 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7638 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007639
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007640 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7641 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7642 // "used"; handle this below.
7643 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007644
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007645 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7646 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7647 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7648 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007649 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007650 return;
7651 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007652
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007653 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007654 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007655 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007656 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007657 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7658 return;
7659 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7660 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007661 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007662 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007663 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007664 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007666
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007667 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007668 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007669 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007670 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007671 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7672 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007673 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7674 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7675 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007676 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007677 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007678 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7679 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007680 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007681 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007682 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007683 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007684 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007685 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7686 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7687 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7688 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7689 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007690 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007691 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007692 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007693 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007694 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7695 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7696 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007697 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007698 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007699 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7700 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007701
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007702 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7703 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7704 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7705 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7706 Loc));
7707 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007708 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007709 Loc));
7710 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007711 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007712
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007713 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007714 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007715
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007716 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007717 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007718
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007719 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007720 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007721 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007722 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7723 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7724 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7725 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7726 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7727 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7728 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7729 }
7730 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007731
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007732 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007733
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007734 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007735 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007736 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007737}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007738
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007739namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007740 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007741 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007742 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007743 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7744 Sema &S;
7745 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007746
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007747 public:
7748 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007749
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007750 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007751
7752 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7753 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007754 };
7755}
7756
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007757bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7758 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007759 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7760 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7761 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007762
7763 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007764}
7765
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007766bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007767 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7768 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7769 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007770 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7771 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007772 }
7773
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007774 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007775}
7776
7777void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7778 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007779 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007780}
7781
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007782/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7783/// of the program being compiled.
7784///
7785/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007786/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007787/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7788/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7789/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7790/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007791/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007792/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007793///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007794/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7795/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7796/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7797/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007798bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007799 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7800 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7801 case Unevaluated:
7802 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7803 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007804
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007805 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7806 Diag(Loc, PD);
7807 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007808
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007809 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7810 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7811 break;
7812 }
7813
7814 return false;
7815}
7816
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007817bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7818 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7819 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7820 return false;
7821
7822 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7823 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7824 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7825 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007826
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007827 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007828 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007829 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7830 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007831 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007832 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7833 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7834 return true;
7835
7836 return false;
7837}
7838
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007839// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7840// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7841void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7842 SourceLocation Loc;
7843
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007844 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7845
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007846 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7847 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7848 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7849 return;
7850
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007851 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7852 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7853 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7854 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7855
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007856 // self = [<foo> init...]
7857 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7858 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7859 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7860
7861 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7862 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7863 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7864 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7865 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007866
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007867 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7868 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7869 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7870 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7871 return;
7872
7873 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7874 } else {
7875 // Not an assignment.
7876 return;
7877 }
7878
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007879 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007880 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007881
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007882 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007883 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007884 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007885 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7886 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7887 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007888}
7889
7890bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7891 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7892
7893 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007894 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007895
7896 QualType T = E->getType();
7897
7898 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7899 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7900 return true;
7901 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7902 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7903 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7904 return true;
7905 }
7906 }
7907
7908 return false;
7909}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007910
7911Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7912 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007913 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7914 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007915 return ExprError();
7916
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007917 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007918 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007919
7920 return Owned(Sub);
7921}